blob: 53502c06283c12259f2ee58b330e20cce2952f93 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -050037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG file to find out who contributed
38the specific port. In addition, there are various MAINTAINERS files
39scattered throughout the U-Boot source identifying the people or
40companies responsible for various boards and subsystems.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000041
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -050042Note: As of August, 2010, there is no longer a CHANGELOG file in the
43actual U-Boot source tree; however, it can be created dynamically
44from the Git log using:
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000045
46 make CHANGELOG
47
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000048
49Where to get help:
50==================
51
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000052In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -050053U-Boot, you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050054<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
55on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
56Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
57http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000058
59
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010060Where to get source code:
61=========================
62
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -050063The U-Boot source code is maintained in the Git repository at
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010064git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
65http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
66
67The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020068any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010069available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
70directory.
71
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010072Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010073ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
74
75
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000076Where we come from:
77===================
78
79- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000080- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000081- clean up code
82- make it easier to add custom boards
83- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
84- extend functions, especially:
85 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
86 * S-Record download
87 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020088 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +020092- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000093
94
95Names and Spelling:
96===================
97
98The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
99"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
100in source files etc.). Example:
101
102 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
103
104File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
105
106 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
107
108 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
109
110Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
111the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
112
113 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
114 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000115
116
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000117Versioning:
118===========
119
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200120Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
121were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
122into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
123names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
124Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
125releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000126
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000128 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200129 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
Jelle van der Waa0de21ec2016-10-30 17:30:30 +0100130 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candidate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000131
132
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000133Directory Hierarchy:
134====================
135
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500136/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900137 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500138 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500140 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500141 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000142 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500143 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400144 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200145 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500146 /sandbox Files generic to HW-independent "sandbox"
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500147 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400148 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500149/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
150/board Board dependent files
Xu Ziyuan740f7e52016-08-26 19:54:49 +0800151/cmd U-Boot commands functions
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500152/common Misc architecture independent functions
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500153/configs Board default configuration files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500154/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
155/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
156/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400157/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500158/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
159/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
160/include Header Files
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500161/lib Library routines generic to all architectures
162/Licenses Various license files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500163/net Networking code
164/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500165/scripts Various build scripts and Makefiles
166/test Various unit test files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500167/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000168
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000169Software Configuration:
170=======================
171
172Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
173rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
174
175There are two classes of configuration variables:
176
177* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
178 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
179 "CONFIG_".
180
181* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
182 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
183 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200184 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000185
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500186Previously, all configuration was done by hand, which involved creating
187symbolic links and editing configuration files manually. More recently,
188U-Boot has added the Kbuild infrastructure used by the Linux kernel,
189allowing you to use the "make menuconfig" command to configure your
190build.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000191
192
193Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
194---------------------------------------------------
195
196For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200197configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000198
199Example: For a TQM823L module type:
200
201 cd u-boot
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200202 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000203
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500204Note: If you're looking for the default configuration file for a board
205you're sure used to be there but is now missing, check the file
206doc/README.scrapyard for a list of no longer supported boards.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000207
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600208Sandbox Environment:
209--------------------
210
211U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
212board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
213specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
214run some of U-Boot's tests.
215
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki6b1978f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530216See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600217
218
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700219Board Initialisation Flow:
220--------------------------
221
222This is the intended start-up flow for boards. This should apply for both
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500223SPL and U-Boot proper (i.e. they both follow the same rules).
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700224
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500225Note: "SPL" stands for "Secondary Program Loader," which is explained in
226more detail later in this file.
227
228At present, SPL mostly uses a separate code path, but the function names
229and roles of each function are the same. Some boards or architectures
230may not conform to this. At least most ARM boards which use
231CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK conform to this.
232
233Execution typically starts with an architecture-specific (and possibly
234CPU-specific) start.S file, such as:
235
236 - arch/arm/cpu/armv7/start.S
237 - arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc83xx/start.S
238 - arch/mips/cpu/start.S
239
240and so on. From there, three functions are called; the purpose and
241limitations of each of these functions are described below.
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700242
243lowlevel_init():
244 - purpose: essential init to permit execution to reach board_init_f()
245 - no global_data or BSS
246 - there is no stack (ARMv7 may have one but it will soon be removed)
247 - must not set up SDRAM or use console
248 - must only do the bare minimum to allow execution to continue to
249 board_init_f()
250 - this is almost never needed
251 - return normally from this function
252
253board_init_f():
254 - purpose: set up the machine ready for running board_init_r():
255 i.e. SDRAM and serial UART
256 - global_data is available
257 - stack is in SRAM
258 - BSS is not available, so you cannot use global/static variables,
259 only stack variables and global_data
260
261 Non-SPL-specific notes:
262 - dram_init() is called to set up DRAM. If already done in SPL this
263 can do nothing
264
265 SPL-specific notes:
266 - you can override the entire board_init_f() function with your own
267 version as needed.
268 - preloader_console_init() can be called here in extremis
269 - should set up SDRAM, and anything needed to make the UART work
270 - these is no need to clear BSS, it will be done by crt0.S
271 - must return normally from this function (don't call board_init_r()
272 directly)
273
274Here the BSS is cleared. For SPL, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined, then at
275this point the stack and global_data are relocated to below
276CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR. For non-SPL, U-Boot is relocated to run at the top of
277memory.
278
279board_init_r():
280 - purpose: main execution, common code
281 - global_data is available
282 - SDRAM is available
283 - BSS is available, all static/global variables can be used
284 - execution eventually continues to main_loop()
285
286 Non-SPL-specific notes:
287 - U-Boot is relocated to the top of memory and is now running from
288 there.
289
290 SPL-specific notes:
291 - stack is optionally in SDRAM, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined and
292 CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR points into SDRAM
293 - preloader_console_init() can be called here - typically this is
Ley Foon Tan0680f1b2017-05-03 17:13:32 +0800294 done by selecting CONFIG_SPL_BOARD_INIT and then supplying a
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700295 spl_board_init() function containing this call
296 - loads U-Boot or (in falcon mode) Linux
297
298
299
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000300Configuration Options:
301----------------------
302
303Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
304such information is kept in a configuration file
305"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
306
307Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
308"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
309
310
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000311Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
312kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
313build a config tool - later.
314
Ashish Kumar63b23162017-08-11 11:09:14 +0530315- ARM Platform Bus Type(CCI):
316 CoreLink Cache Coherent Interconnect (CCI) is ARM BUS which
317 provides full cache coherency between two clusters of multi-core
318 CPUs and I/O coherency for devices and I/O masters
319
320 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_CCI400
321
322 Defined For SoC that has cache coherent interconnect
323 CCN-400
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000324
Ashish Kumarc055cee2017-08-18 10:54:36 +0530325 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_CCN504
326
327 Defined for SoC that has cache coherent interconnect CCN-504
328
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000329The following options need to be configured:
330
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500331- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000332
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500333- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200334
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530335- Marvell Family Member
336 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
337 multiple fs option at one time
338 for marvell soc family
339
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600340- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000341 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
342
343 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
344 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
345 compliance, among other possible reasons.
346
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600347 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
348
349 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
350 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
351 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
352
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500353 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
354
355 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
356 tree nodes for the given platform.
357
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000358 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
359
360 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
361 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
362 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
363
364 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
365 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
366
367 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
368 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
369
370 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
371 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
372 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
373 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
374
375 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
376 this erratum.
377
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530378 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
379 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800380 required during NOR boot.
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530381
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530382 CONFIG_A008044_WORKAROUND
383 Enables a workaround for T1040/T1042 erratum A008044. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800384 required during NAND boot and valid for Rev 1.0 SoC revision
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530385
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000386 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
387
388 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
389 according to the A004510 workaround.
390
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530391 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
392 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
393 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
394
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530395 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
396 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
397 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
398
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530399 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
400 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
401 connected to the DSP core.
402
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530403 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
404 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
405
Priyanka Jainb1359912013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530406 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
407 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
408 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
409 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
410
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530411 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
412 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
Bin Menga1875592016-02-05 19:30:11 -0800413 time of U-Boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530414
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800415 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800416 Indicates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800417 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
418
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000419- Generic CPU options:
420 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
421
422 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
423 values is arch specific.
424
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700425 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
426 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
427 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
428 SoCs.
429
430 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
431 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
432
433 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
434 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
435 deskew training are not available.
436
437 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
438 Freescale DDR1 controller.
439
440 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
441 Freescale DDR2 controller.
442
443 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
444 Freescale DDR3 controller.
445
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700446 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
447 Freescale DDR4 controller.
448
York Sun9ac4ffb2013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700449 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
450 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
451
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700452 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
453 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
454 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
455 implemetation.
456
457 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
Robert P. J. Day62a3b7d2016-07-15 13:44:45 -0400458 Board config to use DDR2. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700459 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
460 implementation.
461
462 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
463 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700464 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
465
466 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
467 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
468 DDR3L controllers.
469
470 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
471 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
472 DDR4 controllers.
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700473
Prabhakar Kushwaha1b4175d2014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530474 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
475 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
476
477 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
478 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
479
Prabhakar Kushwaha1c407072017-02-02 15:01:26 +0530480 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_CLK_DIV
481 Defines divider of platform clock(clock input to IFC controller).
482
Prabhakar Kushwahaadd63f92017-02-02 15:02:00 +0530483 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_LBC_CLK_DIV
484 Defines divider of platform clock(clock input to eLBC controller).
485
Prabhakar Kushwaha690e4252014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530486 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
487 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
488 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
489
490 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
491 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
492 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
493 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
494
Prabhakar Kushwaha89ad7be2014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530495 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
496 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
497 concatenated with u-boot binary.
498
York Sun4e5b1bd2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800499 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
500 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
501
502 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
503 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
504
York Sun6b9e3092014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800505 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
506 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
507 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
508 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
509
York Sun6b1e1252014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800510 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
511 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
512 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
513 SoCs with ARM core.
514
York Sun1d71efb2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700515 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
516 Number of controllers used as main memory.
517
518 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
519 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
520
Prabhakar Kushwaha44937212015-11-09 16:42:07 +0530521 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_DP_DDR
522 Defines the SoC has DP-DDR used for DPAA.
523
Ruchika Gupta028dbb82014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530524 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
525 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
526
527 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
528 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
529
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200530- MIPS CPU options:
531 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
532
533 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
534 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
535 relocation.
536
537 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
538
539 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
540 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
541 Possible values are:
542 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
543 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
544 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
545 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
546 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
547 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
548 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
549 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
550
551 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
552
553 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
554 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
555
556 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
557
558 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
559 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
560 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
561
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000562- ARM options:
563 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
564
565 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
566 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
567
York Sun207774b2015-03-20 19:28:08 -0700568 COUNTER_FREQUENCY
569 Generic timer clock source frequency.
570
571 COUNTER_FREQUENCY_REAL
572 Generic timer clock source frequency if the real clock is
573 different from COUNTER_FREQUENCY, and can only be determined
574 at run time.
575
Stephen Warren73c38932015-01-19 16:25:52 -0700576- Tegra SoC options:
577 CONFIG_TEGRA_SUPPORT_NON_SECURE
578
579 Support executing U-Boot in non-secure (NS) mode. Certain
580 impossible actions will be skipped if the CPU is in NS mode,
581 such as ARM architectural timer initialization.
582
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000583- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000584 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
585
586 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
587 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
588 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
589 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
590 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
591 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
592 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000593 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100594 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000595 default environment.
596
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000597 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
598
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800599 When transferring memsize parameter to Linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000600 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
601 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
602
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400603 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200604
605 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400606 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
607 concepts).
608
609 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
610 * New libfdt-based support
611 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500612 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400613
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200614 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600615 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200616
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200617 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
618 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500619
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600620 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
621
622 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
623 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000624
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -0600625 CONFIG_OF_SYSTEM_SETUP
626
627 Other code has addition modification that it wants to make
628 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel.
629 This causes ft_system_setup() to be called before booting
630 the kernel.
631
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200632 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
633
634 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
635 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
636 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
637 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
638 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
639 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
640
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000641 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
642
643 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
644 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
645 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
646 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
647 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
648 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
649 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
650
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100651- vxWorks boot parameters:
652
653 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
Bin Meng9e98b7e2015-10-07 20:19:17 -0700654 environments variables: bootdev, bootfile, ipaddr, netmask,
655 serverip, gatewayip, hostname, othbootargs.
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100656 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
657
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100658 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
659 the defaults discussed just above.
660
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000661- Cache Configuration:
662 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
663 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
664 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
665
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000666- Cache Configuration for ARM:
667 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
668 controller
669 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
670 controller register space
671
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000672- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200673 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000674
675 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
676
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200677 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000678
679 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
680
681 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
682
683 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
684 the clock speed of the UARTs.
685
686 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
687
688 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
689 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
690 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
691
Karicheri, Muralidharand57dee52014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400692 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
693
694 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
695 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000696
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000697- Console Baudrate:
698 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
699 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200700 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000701
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000702- Autoboot Command:
703 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
704 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
705 define a command string that is automatically executed
706 when no character is read on the console interface
707 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
708
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000709 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000710 The value of these goes into the environment as
711 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
712 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200713 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000714
Heiko Schochereda0ba32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100715- Bootcount:
716 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
717 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
718 cycle, see:
719 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
720
721 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
722 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
723 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
724 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
725 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
726 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
727 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
728 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
729 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
730
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000731- Pre-Boot Commands:
732 CONFIG_PREBOOT
733
734 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
735 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
736 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
737 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
738 entering interactive mode.
739
740 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
741 automatically generated or modified. For an example
742 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
743 modified when the user holds down a certain
744 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
745 booting the systems
746
747- Serial Download Echo Mode:
748 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
749 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
750 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
751 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
752 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
753 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
754 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
755
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500756- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000757 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
758 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200759 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000760
Simon Glass302a6482016-03-13 19:07:28 -0600761- Removal of commands
762 If no commands are needed to boot, you can disable
763 CONFIG_CMDLINE to remove them. In this case, the command line
764 will not be available, and when U-Boot wants to execute the
765 boot command (on start-up) it will call board_run_command()
766 instead. This can reduce image size significantly for very
767 simple boot procedures.
768
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +0000769- Regular expression support:
770 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +0200771 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
772 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
773 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
774 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +0000775
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000776- Device tree:
777 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
778 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
779 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
780 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
781 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
782 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
783
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000784 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
Alex Deymo82f766d2017-04-02 01:25:20 -0700785 be done using one of the three options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000786
787 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
788 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
789 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
790 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
791 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
Nobuhiro Iwamatsueb3eb602017-08-26 07:34:14 +0900792 the global data structure as gd->fdt_blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000793
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000794 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
795 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
796 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
797 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
798
799 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
800
801 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
802 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
803 still use the individual files if you need something more
804 exotic.
805
Alex Deymo82f766d2017-04-02 01:25:20 -0700806 CONFIG_OF_BOARD
807 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use the device tree
808 provided by the board at runtime instead of embedding one with
809 the image. Only boards defining board_fdt_blob_setup() support
810 this option (see include/fdtdec.h file).
811
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000812- Watchdog:
813 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
814 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000815 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
Christophe Leroy907208c2017-07-06 10:23:22 +0200816 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx
817 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
818 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
819 available, then no further board specific code should
820 be needed to use it.
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000821
822 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
823 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
824 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
825 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000826
Heiko Schocher7bae0d62015-01-21 08:38:22 +0100827 CONFIG_AT91_HW_WDT_TIMEOUT
828 specify the timeout in seconds. default 2 seconds.
829
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000830- U-Boot Version:
831 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
832 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
833 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
834 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e512012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200835 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
836 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000837
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000838- Real-Time Clock:
839
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500840 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000841 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
842 following options:
843
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000844 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000845 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000846 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000847 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000848 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000849 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel412921d2014-07-21 11:06:16 +0200850 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000851 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +0100852 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +0000853 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Chris Packham2bd3cab2017-05-30 12:03:33 +1200854 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +0200855 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
856 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000857
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +0000858 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
859 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
860
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600861- GPIO Support:
862 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600863
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +0000864 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
865 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
866 pins supported by a particular chip.
867
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600868 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
869 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
870
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -0600871- I/O tracing:
872 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
873 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
874 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
875 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
876 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
877 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
878 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
879 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
880
881 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
882 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
883 still continue to operate.
884
885 iotrace is enabled
886 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
887 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
888 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
889 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
890 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
891 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
892
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000893- Timestamp Support:
894
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000895 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
896 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
897 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500898 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000899
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000900- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
901 Zero or more of the following:
902 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000903 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
904 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
905 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
906 disk/part_efi.c
907 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000908
Simon Glassfc843a02017-05-17 03:25:30 -0600909 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_IDE or
Simon Glassc649e3c2016-05-01 11:36:02 -0600910 CONFIG_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000911 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000912
913- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000914 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
915 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000916
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000917 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
918 be performed by calling the function
919 ide_set_reset(int reset)
920 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000921
922- ATAPI Support:
923 CONFIG_ATAPI
924
925 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
926
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000927- LBA48 Support
928 CONFIG_LBA48
929
930 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +0100931 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000932 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
933 support disks up to 2.1TB.
934
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200935 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000936 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
937 Default is 32bit.
938
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000939- SCSI Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200940 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
941 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
942 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000943 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
944 devices.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000945
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +0200946 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
947 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +0000948
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000949- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +0000950 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +0000951 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
952
953 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
954 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
955 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
956 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
957
958 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
959 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
960 example with the "sspi" command.
961
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000962 CONFIG_EEPRO100
963 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200964 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000965 write routine for first time initialisation.
966
967 CONFIG_TULIP
968 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
969 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
970 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
971
972 CONFIG_NATSEMI
973 Support for National dp83815 chips.
974
975 CONFIG_NS8382X
976 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
977
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000978- NETWORK Support (other):
979
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +0100980 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
981 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
982
983 CONFIG_RMII
984 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
985
986 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
987 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
988 The driver doen't show link status messages.
989
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +0000990 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
991 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
992
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +0000993 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000994 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
995
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000996 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
997 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
998
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +0000999 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001000 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1001
1002 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1003 Define this to hold the physical address
1004 of the device (I/O space)
1005
1006 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1007 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1008
1009 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1010 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1011 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1012
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001013 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1014 Support for davinci emac
1015
1016 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1017 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1018
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001019 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1020 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1021
1022 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1023 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1024 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1025 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1026 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1027 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1028 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1029 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1030
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001031 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1032 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1033
1034 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1035 Define the number of ports to be used
1036
1037 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1038 Define the ETH PHY's address
1039
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001040 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1041 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1042
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001043- PWM Support:
1044 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
Robert P. J. Day5052e812016-09-13 08:35:18 -04001045 Support for PWM module on the imx6.
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001046
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001047- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001048 CONFIG_TPM
1049 Support TPM devices.
1050
Christophe Ricard0766ad22015-10-06 22:54:41 +02001051 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_INFINEON
1052 Support for Infineon i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001053 per system is supported at this time.
1054
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001055 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1056 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1057
Christophe Ricard3aa74082016-01-21 23:27:13 +01001058 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24
1059 Support for STMicroelectronics TPM devices. Requires DM_TPM support.
1060
1061 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24_I2C
1062 Support for STMicroelectronics ST33ZP24 I2C devices.
1063 Requires TPM_ST33ZP24 and I2C.
1064
Christophe Ricardb75fdc12016-01-21 23:27:14 +01001065 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24_SPI
1066 Support for STMicroelectronics ST33ZP24 SPI devices.
1067 Requires TPM_ST33ZP24 and SPI.
1068
Dirk Eibachc01939c2013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001069 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1070 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1071
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001072 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001073 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1074 per system is supported at this time.
1075
1076 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1077 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1078 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1079 0xfed40000.
1080
Reinhard Pfaube6c1522013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001081 CONFIG_TPM
1082 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1083 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1084 Requires support for a TPM device.
1085
1086 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1087 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1088 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1089
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001090- USB Support:
1091 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
Heiko Schocher064b55c2017-06-14 05:49:40 +02001092 supported (PIP405, MIP405); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001093 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1094 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001095 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001096 storage devices.
1097 Note:
1098 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1099 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001100
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001101 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1102 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1103
Oleksandr Tymoshenko6e9e0622014-02-01 21:51:25 -07001104 CONFIG_USB_DWC2_REG_ADDR the physical CPU address of the DWC2
1105 HW module registers.
1106
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001107- USB Device:
1108 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1109 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1110 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001111 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001112 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1113 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001114 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001115 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1116 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1117 a Linux host by
1118 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1119 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1120 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1121 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001122
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001123 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1124 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001125
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001126 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1127 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1128 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001129
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301130 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1131 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1132 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1133 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1134 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1135 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1136 speed.
1137
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001138 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001139 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1140 be set to usbtty.
1141
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001142 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001143 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001144 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001145 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1146 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1147 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1148
1149 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1150 Define this string as the name of your company for
1151 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001152
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001153 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1154 Define this string as the name of your product
1155 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1156
1157 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1158 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1159 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1160 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1161 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001162
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001163 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1164 Define this as the unique Product ID
1165 for your device
1166 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001167
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001168- ULPI Layer Support:
1169 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1170 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1171 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1172 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1173 viewport is supported.
1174 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1175 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001176 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1177 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1178 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001179
1180- MMC Support:
1181 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1182 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1183 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1184 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001185 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1186 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001187
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001188 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1189 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1190
1191 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1192 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1193
1194 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1195 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1196
Pierre Aubert1fd93c62014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001197 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1198 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1199
1200 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
1201 Enable the commands for reading, writing and programming the
1202 key for the Replay Protection Memory Block partition in eMMC.
1203
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001204- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
Paul Kocialkowski01acd6a2015-06-12 19:56:58 +02001205 CONFIG_USB_FUNCTION_DFU
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001206 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1207
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001208 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1209 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1210
Pantelis Antoniouc6631762013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001211 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1212 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1213
Afzal Mohammeda9479f02013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301214 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1215 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1216 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1217 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1218 one that would help mostly the developer.
1219
Heiko Schochere7e75c72013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001220 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1221 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1222 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1223 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1224 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1225
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001226 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1227 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1228 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1229 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1230 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1231 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1232
Heiko Schocher001a8312014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001233 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1234 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1235 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1236 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1237
1238 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1239 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1240 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1241 sending again an USB request to the device.
1242
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001243- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
Simon Glassb2482df2016-10-02 18:00:59 -06001244 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001245 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1246
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001247 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1248 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001249 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1250
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001251- Keyboard Support:
Simon Glass39f615e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -07001252 See Kconfig help for available keyboard drivers.
1253
1254 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
1255
1256 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1257 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1258 defined in your board-specific files. This option is deprecated
1259 and is only used by novena. For new boards, use driver model
1260 instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001261
1262- Video support:
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001263 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001264 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001265 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1266 support, and should also define these other macros:
1267
1268 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1269 CONFIG_VIDEO
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001270 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1271 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1272 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1273 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1274 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1275
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001276 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1277 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
Fabio Estevam8eca9432016-04-02 11:53:18 -03001278 boot. See the documentation file doc/README.video for a
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001279 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001280
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001281- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1282
1283 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1284 display); also select one of the supported displays
1285 by defining one of these:
1286
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001287 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1288
1289 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1290
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001291 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001292
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001293 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001294
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001295 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001296
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001297 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1298 Active, color, single scan.
1299
1300 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1301
1302 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001303 Active, color, single scan.
1304
1305 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1306
1307 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1308 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1309
1310 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1311
1312 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1313 Active, color, single scan.
1314
1315 CONFIG_HLD1045
1316
1317 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1318 Active, color, single scan.
1319
1320 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1321
1322 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1323 or
1324 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1325 or
1326 Hitachi SP14Q002
1327
1328 320x240. Black & white.
1329
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001330 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1331
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001332 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (typically 4KB). If this is
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001333 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1334 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1335 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1336 a per-section basis.
1337
1338
Hannes Petermaier604c7d42015-03-27 08:01:38 +01001339 CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION
1340
1341 Sometimes, for example if the display is mounted in portrait
1342 mode or even if it's mounted landscape but rotated by 180degree,
1343 we need to rotate our content of the display relative to the
1344 framebuffer, so that user can read the messages which are
1345 printed out.
1346 Once CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is defined, the lcd_console will be
1347 initialized with a given rotation from "vl_rot" out of
1348 "vidinfo_t" which is provided by the board specific code.
1349 The value for vl_rot is coded as following (matching to
1350 fbcon=rotate:<n> linux-kernel commandline):
1351 0 = no rotation respectively 0 degree
1352 1 = 90 degree rotation
1353 2 = 180 degree rotation
1354 3 = 270 degree rotation
1355
1356 If CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is not defined, the console will be
1357 initialized with 0degree rotation.
1358
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001359 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1360
1361 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1362
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001363 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1364
1365 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1366 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1367
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001368- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001369
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001370 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1371 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1372 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001373 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001374 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1375 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1376 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1377 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001378
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001379 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1380
1381 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1382 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Fabio Estevamab5645f2016-03-23 12:46:12 -03001383 (see doc/README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001384 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1385 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1386 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1387 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1388 there is no need to set this option.
1389
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001390 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1391
1392 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1393 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1394 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1395 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1396 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1397 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1398
1399 Example:
1400 setenv splashpos m,m
1401 => image at center of screen
1402
1403 setenv splashpos 30,20
1404 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1405
1406 setenv splashpos -10,m
1407 => vertically centered image
1408 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1409
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001410- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1411
1412 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1413 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1414 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1415
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001416- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1417
1418 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1419 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1420 bmp command.
1421
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001422- Compression support:
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001423 CONFIG_GZIP
1424
1425 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
1426
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001427 CONFIG_BZIP2
1428
1429 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1430 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1431 compressed images are supported.
1432
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001433 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001434 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001435 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001436
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001437- MII/PHY support:
1438 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1439
1440 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1441
1442 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1443
1444 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1445
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001446 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1447
1448 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1449 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1450 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1451 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1452
1453 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1454
1455 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1456 command issued before MII status register can be read
1457
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001458- IP address:
1459 CONFIG_IPADDR
1460
1461 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001462 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001463 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001464 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001465
1466- Server IP address:
1467 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1468
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001469 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001470 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001471 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001472
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001473 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1474
1475 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1476 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1477
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001478- Gateway IP address:
1479 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1480
1481 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1482 default router where packets to other networks are
1483 sent to.
1484 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1485
1486- Subnet mask:
1487 CONFIG_NETMASK
1488
1489 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1490 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1491 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1492 forwarded through a router.
1493 (Environment variable "netmask")
1494
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001495- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1496 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1497
1498 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1499 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001500 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001501 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1502 multicast group.
1503
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001504- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1505 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1506
1507 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1508 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1509 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1510 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1511 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1512 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1513 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1514 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001515 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001516
1517 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1518 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1519 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1520 4th and following
1521 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1522
Thierry Reding92ac8ac2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02001523 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
1524
1525 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
1526 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
1527 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
1528 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
1529 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
1530 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
1531 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
1532 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
1533 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
1534 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
1535 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
1536 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
1537 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
1538 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
1539 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
1540
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001541- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001542 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1543 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001544
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001545 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1546 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1547 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1548 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1549 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1550 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1551 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1552 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1553 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1554 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1555 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1556 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001557 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001558
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001559 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1560 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001561
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001562 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1563 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1564 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1565 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1566 is not available.
1567
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001568 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1569 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1570 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1571 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1572 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1573 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1574 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001575 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001576
1577 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1578 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1579 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001580 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001581 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1582 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001583
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001584 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1585
1586 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1587 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1588 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1589 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1590 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1591 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1592 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1593 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1594 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1595 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1596 this delay.
1597
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001598 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1599 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1600 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1601 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1602 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1603
1604 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1605
Prabhakar Kushwaha24acb832017-11-23 16:51:32 +05301606 - MAC address from environment variables
1607
1608 FDT_SEQ_MACADDR_FROM_ENV
1609
1610 Fix-up device tree with MAC addresses fetched sequentially from
1611 environment variables. This config work on assumption that
1612 non-usable ethernet node of device-tree are either not present
1613 or their status has been marked as "disabled".
1614
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001615 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001616 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001617
1618 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1619
1620 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1621
1622 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1623 of the device.
1624
1625 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1626
1627 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1628 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001629 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001630
1631 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1632
1633 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1634 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1635
1636 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1637
1638 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1639
1640 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1641
1642 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1643
1644 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1645
1646 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1647
1648 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1649
1650 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1651 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1652
1653 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1654
1655 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1656
Uri Mashiach79267ed2017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001657- Status LED: CONFIG_LED_STATUS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001658
1659 Several configurations allow to display the current
1660 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1661 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1662 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1663 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1664 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
Uri Mashiach79267ed2017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001665 kernel). Defining CONFIG_LED_STATUS enables this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001666 feature in U-Boot.
1667
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001668 Additional options:
1669
Uri Mashiach79267ed2017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001670 CONFIG_LED_STATUS_GPIO
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001671 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
1672 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
Uri Mashiach79267ed2017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001673 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_LED_STATUS_GPIO
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001674 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
1675
Igor Grinberg9dfdcdf2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02001676 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
1677 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
1678 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
1679 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
1680 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
1681 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
1682
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001683- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001684
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001685 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
1686 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
1687 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
1688 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
1689 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
1690 interface.
1691
1692 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001693 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
1694 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
1695 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
1696 for defining speed and slave address
1697 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
1698 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
1699 for defining speed and slave address
1700 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
1701 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
1702 for defining speed and slave address
1703 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
1704 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
1705 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001706
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02001707 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
1708 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
1709 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
1710 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
1711 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
1712 bus.
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001713 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02001714 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
1715 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
1716 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
1717 second bus.
1718
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00001719 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu10cee512013-10-11 16:23:53 +09001720 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
1721 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
1722 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00001723
Dirk Eibach880540d2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00001724 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
1725 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
1726 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
1727 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
1728
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001729 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
1730 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)03544c62015-09-21 22:43:38 +02001731 - enable bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C1
1732 - enable bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C2
1733 - enable bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C3
1734 - enable bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C4
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001735 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
1736 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
1737 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
1738 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
1739 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
1740 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)03544c62015-09-21 22:43:38 +02001741 - define speed for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SPEED
1742 - define slave for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SLAVE
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001743 If those defines are not set, default value is 100000
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001744 for speed, and 0 for slave.
1745
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1086bfa2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09001746 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
1747 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
1748 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
1749
1750 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
1751 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
1752 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
1753 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
1754 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
1755 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
1756 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
1757 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
1758 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
1759
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09001760 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
1761 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
1762 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
1763
1764 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
1765 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
1766 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
1767 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
1768 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
1769 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
1770 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
1771 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
1772 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
1773 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001774 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09001775
Heiko Schocher6789e842013-10-22 11:03:18 +02001776 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
1777 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
1778 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
1779 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
1780 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
1781 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
1782 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
1783 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
1784 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
1785 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
1786 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
1787 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
1788
Heiko Schocher0bdffe72013-11-08 07:30:53 +01001789 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
1790 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
1791 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
1792 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
1793
Naveen Krishna Che717fc62013-12-06 12:12:38 +05301794 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
1795 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
1796 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
1797 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
1798 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
1799
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02001800 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
1801 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
1802 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
1803 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
1804 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
1805 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
1806 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
1807 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
1808 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
1809 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
1810 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
1811 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
1812 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
1813 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
Dirk Eibach071be892015-10-28 11:46:22 +01001814 - activate dual channel with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_DUAL
1815 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0_1 speed channel 0_1
1816 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0_1 slave addr channel 0_1
1817 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1_1 speed channel 1_1
1818 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1_1 slave addr channel 1_1
1819 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2_1 speed channel 2_1
1820 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2_1 slave addr channel 2_1
1821 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3_1 speed channel 3_1
1822 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3_1 slave addr channel 3_1
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02001823
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001824 additional defines:
1825
1826 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
Simon Glass945a18e2016-10-02 18:01:05 -06001827 Hold the number of i2c buses you want to use.
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001828
1829 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
1830 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
1831 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
1832 omit this define.
1833
1834 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
1835 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
1836 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
1837 define.
1838
1839 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001840 hold a list of buses you want to use, only used if
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001841 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
1842 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
1843 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
1844
1845 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
1846 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
1847 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
1848 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
1849 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
1850 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
1851 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
1852 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
1853 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
1854 }
1855
1856 which defines
1857 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001858 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
1859 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
1860 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
1861 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
1862 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001863 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001864 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
1865 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001866
1867 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
1868
Simon Glassce3b5d62017-05-12 21:10:00 -06001869- Legacy I2C Support:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001870 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001871 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1872 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001873
1874 I2C_INIT
1875
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001876 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001877 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001878
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001879 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001880
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001881 I2C_ACTIVE
1882
1883 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1884 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1885 define can be null.
1886
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001887 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1888
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001889 I2C_TRISTATE
1890
1891 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1892 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1893 define can be null.
1894
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001895 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1896
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001897 I2C_READ
1898
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001899 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
1900 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001901
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001902 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1903
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001904 I2C_SDA(bit)
1905
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001906 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1907 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001908
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001909 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001910 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001911 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001912
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001913 I2C_SCL(bit)
1914
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001915 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1916 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001917
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001918 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001919 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001920 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001921
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001922 I2C_DELAY
1923
1924 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1925 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001926 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001927 like:
1928
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001929 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001930
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001931 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1932
1933 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1934 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1935 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1936 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1937
1938 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1939 the generic GPIO functions.
1940
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001941 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001942
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001943 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1944 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1945 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1946 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1947 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1948 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1949 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1950 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001951
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001952 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1953
1954 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001955 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
1956 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001957 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
1958
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001959 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001960
1961 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001962 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05001963 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
1964 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001965
1966 e.g.
1967 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001968 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001969
1970 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
1971
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001972 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Simon Glass945a18e2016-10-02 18:01:05 -06001973 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001974
1975 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
1976
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001977 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001978
1979 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
1980 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
1981
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001982 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001983
1984 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
1985 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
1986
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06001987 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
1988
1989 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
1990 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
1991 between writing the address pointer and reading the
1992 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
1993 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
1994 devices can use either method, but some require one or
1995 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001996
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001997- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
1998
1999 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2000 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2001 D/As on the SACSng board)
2002
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002003 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2004
2005 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2006 only SH7757 is supported.
2007
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002008 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2009
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002010 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2011 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2012 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2013 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2014 defined, the board configuration must define several
2015 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2016 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002017
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002018 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2019
2020 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2021 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2022 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002023 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002024 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2025
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002026 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2027
2028 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002029 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002030
Heiko Schocherf659b572014-07-14 10:22:11 +02002031 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
2032 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
2033 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
2034
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002035- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2036
2037 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2038
2039 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2040
2041 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2042 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2043
2044 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2045
2046 Enables support for FPGA family.
2047 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2048
2049 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002050
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002051 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002052
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002053 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002054
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002055 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002056
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002057 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002058
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002059 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2060 status by the configuration function. This option
2061 will require a board or device specific function to
2062 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002063
2064 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2065
2066 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2067 configuration driver.
2068
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002069 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002070 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2071
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002072 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002073
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002074 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2075 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2076 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2077 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002078
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002079 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002080
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002081 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to de-assert
2082 after PROB_B has been de-asserted during a Virtex II
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002083 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002084 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002085
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002086 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002087
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002088 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to de-assert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002089 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002090
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002091 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002092
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002093 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002094 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002095
2096- Configuration Management:
Stefan Roeseb2b8a692014-10-22 12:13:24 +02002097 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET
2098
2099 Some SoCs need special image types (e.g. U-Boot binary
2100 with a special header) as build targets. By defining
2101 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET in the SoC / board header, this
2102 special image will be automatically built upon calling
Simon Glass6de80f22016-07-27 20:33:08 -06002103 make / buildman.
Stefan Roeseb2b8a692014-10-22 12:13:24 +02002104
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002105 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2106
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002107 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2108 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002109
2110- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2111
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002112 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2113 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002114 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002115 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2116 protects these variables from casual modification by
2117 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2118 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002119 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002120
2121 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2122 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002123 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002124 these parameters.
2125
Joe Hershberger92ac5202015-05-04 14:55:14 -05002126 Alternatively, if you define _both_ an ethaddr in the
2127 default env _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002128 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002129 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2130 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2131 read-only.]
2132
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002133 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2134 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2135 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2136 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2137
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002138- Protected RAM:
2139 CONFIG_PRAM
2140
2141 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2142 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2143 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2144 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2145 this default value by defining an environment
2146 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2147 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2148 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2149 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2150 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2151 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2152 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2153
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002154 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002155 saveenv
2156
2157 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2158 either, which results in a memory region that will
2159 not be affected by reboots.
2160
2161 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2162 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2163 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2164 following board configurations are known to be
2165 "pRAM-clean":
2166
Heiko Schocher5b8e76c2017-06-07 17:33:09 +02002167 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx,
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002168 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Heiko Schocher2eb48ff2017-06-07 17:33:10 +02002169 FLAGADM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002170
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002171- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2172 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2173 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2174 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2175 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2176 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2177 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2178
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002179- Error Recovery:
2180 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2181
2182 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2183 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2184 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002185 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002186 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2187 useful during development since you can try to debug
2188 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2189
2190 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2191
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002192 This variable defines the number of retries for
2193 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2194 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2195 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002196
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002197 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2198
2199 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2200
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002201 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2202
2203 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2204 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2205 try longer timeout such as
2206 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2207
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002208- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002209 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002210
2211 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002213 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002214
2215 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2216 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2217 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2218
2219 Note:
2220
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002221 In the current implementation, the local variables
2222 space and global environment variables space are
2223 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2224 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2225 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2226 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2227 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002228
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002229 Global environment variables are those you use
2230 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2231 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2232 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002233
2234 To store commands and special characters in a
2235 variable, please use double quotation marks
2236 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2237 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2238 symbols.
2239
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002240- Command Line Editing and History:
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002241 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2242
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002243 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002244 command line input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002245
Marek Vasutf3b267b2016-01-27 04:47:55 +01002246- Command Line PS1/PS2 support:
2247 CONFIG_CMDLINE_PS_SUPPORT
2248
2249 Enable support for changing the command prompt string
2250 at run-time. Only static string is supported so far.
2251 The string is obtained from environment variables PS1
2252 and PS2.
2253
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002254- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002255 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2256
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002257 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2258 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002259 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002260
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002261 For example, place something like this in your
2262 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002263
2264 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2265 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2266 "myvar2=value2\0"
2267
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002268 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2269 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2270 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2271 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002272 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002273 You better know what you are doing here.
2274
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002275 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2276 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002277 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002278 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002279
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002280 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2281
2282 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2283 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2284 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2285
2286 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2287
2288 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2289 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2290 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2291 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2292 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2293
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002294 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2295
2296 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2297 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2298 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2299
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002300 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2301
2302 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002303 initialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002304 that so that the environment is not available until
2305 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2306 this is instead controlled by the value of
2307 /config/load-environment.
2308
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002309- Serial Flash support
Simon Glass00fd59d2017-08-04 16:35:06 -06002310 Usage requires an initial 'sf probe' to define the serial
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002311 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2312 commands.
2313
2314 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2315 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2316 flash is present on the system.
2317
2318 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2319 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2320 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2321 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2322
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002323 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2324
2325 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2326 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002327 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002328 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002329
2330 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002331 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002332
2333 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2334 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2335
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002336- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2337 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2338
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002339 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002340 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002341 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002342 number generator is used.
2343
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002344 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2345 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2346 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2347
2348 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002349 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2350 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2351 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2352 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2353 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2354 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2355
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01002356- bootcount support:
2357 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
2358
2359 This enables the bootcounter support, see:
2360 http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
2361
2362 CONFIG_AT91SAM9XE
2363 enable special bootcounter support on at91sam9xe based boards.
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01002364 CONFIG_SOC_DA8XX
2365 enable special bootcounter support on da850 based boards.
2366 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_RAM
2367 enable support for the bootcounter in RAM
2368 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_I2C
2369 enable support for the bootcounter on an i2c (like RTC) device.
2370 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RTC_ADDR = i2c chip address
2371 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = i2c addr which is used for
2372 the bootcounter.
2373 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ALEN = address len
Ian Rayf31dac42017-11-08 15:35:13 +00002374 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_EXT
2375 enable support for the bootcounter in EXT filesystem
2376 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = RAM address used for read
2377 and write.
2378 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_EXT_INTERFACE = interface
2379 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_EXT_DEVPART = device and part
2380 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_EXT_NAME = filename
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07002381
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002382- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002383 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2384
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002385 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2386 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2387 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2388 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2389 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2390 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002391
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002392
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002393Legacy uImage format:
2394
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002395 Arg Where When
2396 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002397 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002398 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002399 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002400 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002401 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002402 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2403 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2404 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002405 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002406 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2407 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2408 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2409 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002410 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002411 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002412
2413 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2414 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2415 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2416 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2417 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2418 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2419 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002420 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002421 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2422 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2423
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002424 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002425
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002426 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd542004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002427 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2428 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002429
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002430 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2431 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2432 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2433 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2434 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2435 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2436 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2437 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2438 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2439 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2440 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2441 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2442 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2443 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2444 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2445 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2446 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2447 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2448 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2449 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2450 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2451 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2452 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2453 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2454 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2455 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2456 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2457 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2458 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2459 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2460 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2461 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2462 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2463 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2464 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2465 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2466 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2467 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2468 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2469 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2470 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2471 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2472 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2473 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2474 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2475 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2476 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002477
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002478 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002479
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002480 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002481 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2482 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002483
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002484 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
Joe Hershbergerbc0571f2015-04-08 01:41:21 -05002485 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling net_loop()
2486 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in net_loop() occurred
2487 81 common/cmd_net.c net_loop() back without error
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002488 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2489 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002490 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2491 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002492 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002493
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002494FIT uImage format:
2495
2496 Arg Where When
2497 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2498 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2499 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2500 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2501 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2502 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002503 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002504 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2505 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2506 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2507 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2508 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002509 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2510 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002511 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2512 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2513 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2514 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2515 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2516 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2517 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2518 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2519
2520 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2521 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2522 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002523 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002524 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2525 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2526 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2527 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2528 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2529 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2530 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2531 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2532 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2533 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2534 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2535 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2536
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002537 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002538 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2539
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002540 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002541 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2542
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002543 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002544 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2545
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02002546- legacy image format:
2547 CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
2548 enables the legacy image format support in U-Boot.
2549
2550 Default:
2551 enabled if CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is not defined.
2552
2553 CONFIG_DISABLE_IMAGE_LEGACY
2554 disable the legacy image format
2555
2556 This define is introduced, as the legacy image format is
2557 enabled per default for backward compatibility.
2558
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002559- Standalone program support:
2560 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2561
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002562 This option defines a board specific value for the
2563 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2564 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002565 settings.
2566
2567- Frame Buffer Address:
2568 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2569
2570 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00002571 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
2572 when using a graphics controller has separate video
2573 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
2574 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
2575 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
2576 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
2577 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002578
2579 Please see board_init_f function.
2580
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002581- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2582 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2583 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2584 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2585
2586 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2587 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2588
2589- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2590 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2591
2592 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2593 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2594
2595 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2596
2597 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2598 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2599
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00002600- UBI support
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00002601 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
2602
2603 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
2604 warnings and errors enabled.
2605
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02002606
2607 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
2608 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
2609 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
2610 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
2611 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
2612 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
2613
2614 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
2615 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
2616 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
2617 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
2618 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
2619
2620 default: 4096
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -06002621
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02002622 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
2623 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
2624 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
2625 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
2626 flash), this value is ignored.
2627
2628 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
2629 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
2630 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
2631 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
2632 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
2633 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
2634
2635 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
2636 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
2637 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
2638 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
2639 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
2640 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
2641 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
2642 partition.
2643
2644 default: 20
2645
2646 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
2647 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
2648 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
2649 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
2650 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
2651 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
2652 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
2653 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
2654 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
2655 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
2656 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
2657 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
2658
2659 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
2660 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
2661 without a fastmap.
2662 default: 0
2663
Heiko Schocher0195a7b2015-10-22 06:19:21 +02002664 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FM_DEBUG
2665 Enable UBI fastmap debug
2666 default: 0
2667
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00002668- UBIFS support
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00002669 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
2670
2671 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
2672 warnings and errors enabled.
2673
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002674- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002675 CONFIG_SPL
2676 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002677
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002678 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2679 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2680
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002681 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
2682 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
2683 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
2684 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00002685 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002686 must not be both defined at the same time.
2687
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002688 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002689 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
2690 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
2691 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
2692 not exceed it.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002693
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002694 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2695 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002696
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002697 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
2698 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
2699 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
2700
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002701 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2702 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2703
2704 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002705 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
2706 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
2707 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00002708 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002709 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002710
2711 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2712 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2713
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)8c80eb32015-03-31 11:40:50 +02002714 CONFIG_SPL_PANIC_ON_RAW_IMAGE
2715 When defined, SPL will panic() if the image it has
2716 loaded does not have a signature.
2717 Defining this is useful when code which loads images
2718 in SPL cannot guarantee that absolutely all read errors
2719 will be caught.
2720 An example is the LPC32XX MLC NAND driver, which will
2721 consider that a completely unreadable NAND block is bad,
2722 and thus should be skipped silently.
2723
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002724 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
2725 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
2726 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
2727 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
2728
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002729 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2730 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Fabio Estevam9ac4fc82015-11-12 12:30:19 -02002731 When this option is set the full malloc is used in SPL and
2732 it is set up by spl_init() and before that, the simple malloc()
2733 can be used if CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F is defined.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002734
2735 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2736 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002737
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002738 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2739 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2740 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2741 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2742
Tom Rini9607faf2014-03-28 12:03:39 -04002743 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
2744 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
2745 See also: doc/README.falcon
2746
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002747 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2748 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2749 about the running system.
2750
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05002751 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
2752 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
2753
Paul Kocialkowskib97300b2014-11-08 23:14:56 +01002754 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_PARTITION
2755 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
2756 used in raw mode
2757
Peter Korsgaard2b75b0a2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00002758 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
2759 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
2760 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
2761
2762 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
2763 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
2764 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
2765 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
2766 (for falcon mode)
2767
Paul Kocialkowskie2ccdf82014-11-08 23:14:55 +01002768 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_FS_BOOT_PARTITION
2769 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
2770 used in fs mode
2771
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002772 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2773 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from filesystem
2774
2775 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002776 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002777 from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002778
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002779 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002780 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002781 when reading from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002782
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00002783 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
2784 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
2785 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
2786 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
2787 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
2788
Prabhakar Kushwaha651fcf62014-04-08 19:12:31 +05302789 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
2790 Avoid SPL relocation
2791
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002792 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
2793 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
2794 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
2795
2796 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
2797 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
2798
2799 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
2800 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
2801
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002802 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002803 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
2804 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002805
Thomas Gleixner6f4e7d32016-07-12 20:28:12 +02002806 CONFIG_SPL_UBI
2807 Support for a lightweight UBI (fastmap) scanner and
2808 loader
2809
Heiko Schocher0c3117b2014-10-31 08:31:00 +01002810 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_RAW_ONLY
2811 Support to boot only raw u-boot.bin images. Use this only
2812 if you need to save space.
2813
Ying Zhang7c8eea52013-08-16 15:16:12 +08002814 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
2815 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
2816 SPL binary.
2817
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002818 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2819 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2820 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2821 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2822 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2823 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002824 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002825
Prabhakar Kushwahafbe76ae2013-12-11 12:42:11 +05302826 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
2827 Add support NAND boot
2828
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002829 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002830 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
2831
2832 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
2833 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
2834
2835 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
2836 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002837
2838 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002839 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002840
2841 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2842 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002843 data. This is used, for example, on davinci platforms.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002844
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002845 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2846 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2847
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002848 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeau6113d3f2013-04-11 09:35:49 +00002849 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
2850 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
2851 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
2852 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
2853 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002854
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05002855 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
2856 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
2857 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
2858 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
2859
Simon Glass87ebee32013-05-08 08:05:59 +00002860 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
2861 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
2862 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
2863 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
2864 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
2865
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08002866- TPL framework
2867 CONFIG_TPL
2868 Enable building of TPL globally.
2869
2870 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
2871 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
2872 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002873 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
2874 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
2875 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08002876
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002877- Interrupt support (PPC):
2878
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002879 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2880 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002881 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002882 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002883 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002884 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002885 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002886 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2887 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2888 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002889
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002890
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002891Board initialization settings:
2892------------------------------
2893
2894During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2895to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2896before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2897following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2898architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2899typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2900
2901- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2902- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2903- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2904- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002905
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002906Configuration Settings:
2907-----------------------
2908
York Sun4d1fd7f2014-02-26 17:03:19 -08002909- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
2910 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
2911
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002912- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002913 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2914
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002915- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2916 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2917
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002918- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002919 prompt for user input.
2920
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002921- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002922
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002923- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002924
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002925- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002926
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002927- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002928 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
2929 booted
2930
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002931- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002932 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
2933
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002934- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002935 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
2936 simple memory test.
2937
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002938- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002939 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002940
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002941- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00002942 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
2943 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
2944
York Sune8149522015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002945- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE
York Sune61a7532016-06-24 16:46:18 -07002946 Only implemented for ARMv8 for now.
York Sune8149522015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002947 If defined, the size of CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE memory
2948 is substracted from total RAM and won't be reported to OS.
2949 This memory can be used as secure memory. A variable
York Sune61a7532016-06-24 16:46:18 -07002950 gd->arch.secure_ram is used to track the location. In systems
York Sune8149522015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002951 the RAM base is not zero, or RAM is divided into banks,
2952 this variable needs to be recalcuated to get the address.
2953
York Sunaabd7dd2015-12-07 11:05:29 -08002954- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002955 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002956 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002957 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002958 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
2959 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
2960 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002961 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002962 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002963 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002964
2965 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
2966 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
2967 be touched.
2968
2969 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
2970 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
2971 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
2972 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
2973 problems.
2974
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002975- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002976 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
2977
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002978- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002979 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
2980
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002981- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002982 Physical start address of Flash memory.
2983
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002984- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002985 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
2986 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02002987 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002988 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002989
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002990- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002991 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
2992 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
2993 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
2994 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002995
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002996- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002997 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
2998
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06002999- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
3000 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
3001 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
3002 will become available before relocation. The address is just
3003 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
3004 space.
3005
3006 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
3007 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
3008 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003009 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotten) when
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003010 U-Boot relocates itself.
3011
Simon Glass38687ae2014-11-10 17:16:54 -07003012- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE
3013 Provides a simple and small malloc() and calloc() for those
3014 boards which do not use the full malloc in SPL (which is
3015 enabled with CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START).
3016
Thierry Reding1dfdd9b2014-12-09 22:25:22 -07003017- CONFIG_SYS_NONCACHED_MEMORY:
3018 Size of non-cached memory area. This area of memory will be
3019 typically located right below the malloc() area and mapped
3020 uncached in the MMU. This is useful for drivers that would
3021 otherwise require a lot of explicit cache maintenance. For
3022 some drivers it's also impossible to properly maintain the
3023 cache. For example if the regions that need to be flushed
3024 are not a multiple of the cache-line size, *and* padding
3025 cannot be allocated between the regions to align them (i.e.
3026 if the HW requires a contiguous array of regions, and the
3027 size of each region is not cache-aligned), then a flush of
3028 one region may result in overwriting data that hardware has
3029 written to another region in the same cache-line. This can
3030 happen for example in network drivers where descriptors for
3031 buffers are typically smaller than the CPU cache-line (e.g.
3032 16 bytes vs. 32 or 64 bytes).
3033
3034 Non-cached memory is only supported on 32-bit ARM at present.
3035
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003036- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003037 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3038 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003039 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003040 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3041
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003042- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003043 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3044 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003045 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3046 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003047 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003048 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003049 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003050 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3051 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3052 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003053
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003054- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3055 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3056 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3057 is enabled.
3058
3059- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3060 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3061 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3062
3063- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3064 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3065 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3066
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003067- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003068 Max number of Flash memory banks
3069
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003070- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003071 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3072
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003073- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003074 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3075
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003076- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003077 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3078
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003079- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003080 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3081
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003082- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003083 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3084
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003085- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003086 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3087 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3088
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003089- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003090
3091 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3092 without this option such a download has to be
3093 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3094 copy from RAM to flash.
3095
3096 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3097 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003098 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3099 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003100 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3101
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003102- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003103 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003104 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3105
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003106- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003107 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3108 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003109
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003110- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3111 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3112 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3113 to the MTD layer.
3114
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003115- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003116 Use buffered writes to flash.
3117
3118- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3119 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3120 write commands.
3121
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003122- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003123 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3124 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3125 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3126 optionally available.
3127
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003128- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3129 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3130 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3131 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3132
Stefan Roese352ef3f2013-04-04 15:53:14 +02003133- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
3134 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
3135 against the source after the write operation. An error message
3136 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
3137 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
3138 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
3139 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
3140 this option if you really know what you are doing.
3141
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003142- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003143 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3144 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003145 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3146 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003147 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003148 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3149
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003150- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3151
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003152 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3153 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3154 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3155 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3156 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003157
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003158- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3159- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003160 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003161 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3162 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
3163 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
3164
3165 The format of the list is:
3166 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003167 access_attribute = [a|r|o|c]
3168 attributes = type_attribute[access_attribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003169 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
3170 list = entry[,list]
3171
3172 The type attributes are:
3173 s - String (default)
3174 d - Decimal
3175 x - Hexadecimal
3176 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
3177 i - IP address
3178 m - MAC address
3179
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003180 The access attributes are:
3181 a - Any (default)
3182 r - Read-only
3183 o - Write-once
3184 c - Change-default
3185
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003186 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3187 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003188 environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003189
3190 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3191 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
3192 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
3193 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
3194 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
3195 ".flags" variable.
3196
Joe Hershbergerbdf1fe42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05003197 If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
3198 regular expression. This allows multiple variables to define the same
3199 flags without explicitly listing them for each variable.
3200
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003201- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
3202 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
3203 access flags.
3204
Gabe Black0d296cc2014-10-15 04:38:30 -06003205- CONFIG_USE_STDINT
3206 If stdint.h is available with your toolchain you can define this
3207 option to enable it. You can provide option 'USE_STDINT=1' when
3208 building U-Boot to enable this.
3209
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003210The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
3211of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
3212following configurations:
3213
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00003214- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
3215
3216 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
3217 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
3218
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003219BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003220in U-Boot initialization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003221console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003222U-Boot will hang.
3223
3224Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3225environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3226keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3227to save the current settings.
3228
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003229BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3230"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003231environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3232but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003233
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003234- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3235
3236 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3237 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3238 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3239
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003240Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003241has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Simon Glass00caae62017-08-03 12:22:12 -06003242created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use env_get_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003243until then to read environment variables.
3244
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003245The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3246is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3247with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3248necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3249"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3250have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003251
3252Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3253the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003254use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003255
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003256- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003257 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003258
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003259 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003260 also needs to be defined.
3261
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003262- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003263 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003264
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003265- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3266 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3267 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3268 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3269 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3270 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3271
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00003272- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
3273 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
3274 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
3275 to do this.
3276
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00003277- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
3278 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
3279 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
3280 present.
3281
Sascha Silbefeb85802013-08-11 16:40:43 +02003282- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
3283 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
3284 build system checks that the actual size does not
3285 exceed it.
3286
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003287Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003288---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003289
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003290- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003291 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3292
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003293- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3294 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3295 PowerPC SOCs.
3296
3297- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3298 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3299 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3300
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003301- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3302 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3303 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003304 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003305 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3306 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3307 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3308
3309 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3310 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3311
3312- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003313 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3314 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003315 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3316 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3317
3318- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3319 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3320 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3321 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3322
3323- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3324 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3325 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3326
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003327- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003328 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003329
3330 the default drive number (default value 0)
3331
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003332 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003333
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003334 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003335 (default value 1)
3336
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003337 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003338
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003339 defines the offset of register from address. It
3340 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003341 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003342
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003343 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3344 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003345 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003346
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003347 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003348 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3349 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003350 source code. It is used to make hardware-dependent
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003351 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003352
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003353- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3354 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3355 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3356 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3357 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3358 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003359 is required.
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003360
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003361- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003362 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
Christophe Leroy907208c2017-07-06 10:23:22 +02003363 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003364
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003365- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003366
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003367 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003368 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3369 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3370 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3371 will become available only after programming the
3372 memory controller and running certain initialization
3373 sequences.
3374
3375 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
Christophe Leroy907208c2017-07-06 10:23:22 +02003376 - MPC8xx: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003377
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003378- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003379
3380 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003381 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3382 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003383 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003384 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Simon Glassacd51f92016-10-02 18:01:06 -06003385 GENERATED_GBL_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003386 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3387 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003388
3389 Note:
3390 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3391 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003392 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003393 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3394 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3395
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003396- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003397
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003398- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003399 SDRAM timing
3400
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003401- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003402 periodic timer for refresh
3403
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003404- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3405 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3406 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3407 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003408 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3409
3410- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003411 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3412 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003413 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3414
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003415- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003416 Only scan through and get the devices on the buses.
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003417 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3418 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3419 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3420 by coreboot or similar.
3421
Gabor Juhos842033e2013-05-30 07:06:12 +00003422- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
3423 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
3424
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003425- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3426 Chip has SRIO or not
3427
3428- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3429 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3430
3431- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3432 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3433
Liu Gangc8b28152013-05-07 16:30:46 +08003434- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
3435 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
3436
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003437- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3438 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3439
3440- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3441 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3442
3443- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3444 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3445
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00003446- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
3447 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
3448 a 16 bit bus.
3449 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00003450 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00003451 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00003452 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003453
3454- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3455 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3456 a default value will be used.
3457
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003458- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003459 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3460 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3461
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003462 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3463 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3464
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003465- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003466 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3467 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3468 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003469
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003470- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3471 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3472 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3473 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3474 header files or board specific files.
3475
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003476- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3477 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3478
York Sune32d59a2015-01-06 13:18:55 -08003479- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_SYNC_REFRESH
3480 Enable sync of refresh for multiple controllers.
3481
York Sun4516ff82015-03-19 09:30:28 -07003482- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_BIST
3483 Enable built-in memory test for Freescale DDR controllers.
3484
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003485- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003486 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3487 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003488
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003489- CONFIG_RMII
3490 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3491 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3492 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3493
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003494- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3495 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3496 The syntax is:
3497
3498 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3499
3500 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3501 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3502 area should have.
3503
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003504- CONFIG_LOOPW
3505 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Simon Glass493f4202017-08-04 16:34:27 -06003506 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003507
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003508- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3509 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3510 "md/mw" commands.
3511 Examples:
3512
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003513 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003514 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3515
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003516 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003517 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3518
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003519 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Simon Glass493f4202017-08-04 16:34:27 -06003520 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003521
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003522- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003523 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003524 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3525 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3526 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003527
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003528 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3529 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3530 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3531 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003532
Simon Glassb5bd0982016-05-05 07:28:06 -06003533- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT_ONLY
3534 [ARM926EJ-S only] This allows just the call to lowlevel_init()
yeongjun Kim90211f72016-07-20 22:56:12 +09003535 to be skipped. The normal CP15 init (such as enabling the
Simon Glassb5bd0982016-05-05 07:28:06 -06003536 instruction cache) is still performed.
3537
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003538- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003539 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3540 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3541 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003542
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003543- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
3544 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3545 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
3546 It is loaded by the SPL.
3547
Ying Zhang5df572f2013-05-20 14:07:23 +08003548- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
3549 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
3550 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
3551 previous 4k of the .text section.
3552
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00003553- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
3554 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
3555 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
3556 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
3557 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
3558 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
3559 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
3560 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
3561
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00003562- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
3563 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
3564 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00003565
Heiko Schocher16678eb2013-11-04 14:05:00 +01003566- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
3567 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
3568
Karicheri, Muralidharan999d7d32014-04-04 13:16:50 -04003569- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
3570 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
3571 driver that uses this:
3572 drivers/mtd/nand/davinci_nand.c
3573
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003574Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3575-----------------------------------
3576
3577The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3578loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3579This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3580are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3581within that device.
3582
Zhao Qiangdcf1d772014-03-21 16:21:44 +08003583- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3584 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
3585 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3586 is also specified.
3587
3588- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
3589 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003590 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3591 is also specified.
3592
3593- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3594 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3595 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3596 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3597 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3598
3599- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3600 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3601 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3602 virtual address in NOR flash.
3603
3604- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3605 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3606 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3607
3608- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3609 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3610 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3611
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003612- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3613 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3614 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003615 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3616 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3617 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003618
J. German Riverab940ca62014-06-23 15:15:55 -07003619Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
3620---------------------------------------------------------
3621The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
3622"firmware".
3623This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3624are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3625within that device.
3626
3627- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
3628 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
3629
Prabhakar Kushwaha5c055082015-06-02 10:55:52 +05303630Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support:
3631-------------------------------------------
3632The Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support supports the loading of
3633"Debug Server firmware" and triggering SP boot-rom.
3634This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting.
3635
York Sunc0492142015-12-07 11:08:58 -08003636- CONFIG_SYS_MC_RSV_MEM_ALIGN
3637 Define alignment of reserved memory MC requires
Prabhakar Kushwaha5c055082015-06-02 10:55:52 +05303638
Paul Kocialkowskif3f431a2015-07-26 18:48:15 +02003639Reproducible builds
3640-------------------
3641
3642In order to achieve reproducible builds, timestamps used in the U-Boot build
3643process have to be set to a fixed value.
3644
3645This is done using the SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH environment variable.
3646SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH is to be set on the build host's shell, not as a configuration
3647option for U-Boot or an environment variable in U-Boot.
3648
3649SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH should be set to a number of seconds since the epoch, in UTC.
3650
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003651Building the Software:
3652======================
3653
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003654Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3655and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3656all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3657(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3658recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3659which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003660
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003661If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3662have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3663you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3664Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3665necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003666
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003667 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3668 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003669
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003670Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3671 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3672 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3673 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3674
3675 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3676
3677 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3678 be executed on computers running Windows.
3679
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003680U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3681sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003682is done by typing:
3683
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003684 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003685
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003686where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003687rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003688
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003689Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3690 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3691 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3692 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003693 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003694
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003695 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003696 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003697
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003698 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003699 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003700
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003701 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003702
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003703
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003704Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3705images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003706
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003707- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3708- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3709- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003710
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003711By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3712in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3713this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3714
37151. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3716
3717 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003718 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003719 make O=/tmp/build all
3720
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +020037212. Set environment variable KBUILD_OUTPUT to point to the desired location:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003722
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02003723 export KBUILD_OUTPUT=/tmp/build
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003724 make distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003725 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003726 make all
3727
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02003728Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the KBUILD_OUTPUT environment
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003729variable.
3730
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003731
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003732Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
3733for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
3734native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003735
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003736
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003737If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
3738to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
3739steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003740
Phil Sutter3c1496c2015-12-25 14:41:18 +010037411. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003742 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
Phil Sutter3c1496c2015-12-25 14:41:18 +01003743 the "Makefile" and a "<board>.c".
37442. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
3745 your board.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000037463. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
3747 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +020037484. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000037495. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
3750 to be installed on your target system.
37516. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
3752 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003753
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003754
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003755Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
3756==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003757
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003758If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
3759or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003760provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
3761the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003762official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003763
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003764But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
3765cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003766the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
Simon Glass6de80f22016-07-27 20:33:08 -06003767just run the buildman script (tools/buildman/buildman), which will
3768configure and build U-Boot for ALL supported system. Be warned, this
3769will take a while. Please see the buildman README, or run 'buildman -H'
3770for documentation.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003771
3772
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003773See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003774
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003775
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003776Monitor Commands - Overview:
3777============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003778
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003779go - start application at address 'addr'
3780run - run commands in an environment variable
3781bootm - boot application image from memory
3782bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00003783bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003784tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
3785 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
3786 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00003787tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003788rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
3789diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
3790loads - load S-Record file over serial line
3791loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
3792md - memory display
3793mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
3794nm - memory modify (constant address)
3795mw - memory write (fill)
3796cp - memory copy
3797cmp - memory compare
3798crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05003799i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003800sspi - SPI utility commands
3801base - print or set address offset
3802printenv- print environment variables
3803setenv - set environment variables
3804saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
3805protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
3806erase - erase FLASH memory
3807flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00003808nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003809bdinfo - print Board Info structure
3810iminfo - print header information for application image
3811coninfo - print console devices and informations
3812ide - IDE sub-system
3813loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003814loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003815mtest - simple RAM test
3816icache - enable or disable instruction cache
3817dcache - enable or disable data cache
3818reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
3819echo - echo args to console
3820version - print monitor version
3821help - print online help
3822? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003823
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003824
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003825Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
3826========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003827
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003828TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003829
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003830For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003831
3832
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003833Environment Variables:
3834======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003835
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003836U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
3837can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003838
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003839Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
3840"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
3841without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
3842environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
3843working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
3844environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003845
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003846Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
3847
3848List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003849
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003850 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003851
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003852 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003853
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003854 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003855
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003856 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003857
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003858 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003859
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003860 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3861 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3862 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
3863 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
3864 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
3865 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003866 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
3867 bootm_mapsize.
3868
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003869 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003870 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
3871 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
3872 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
3873 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
3874 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
3875 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003876
3877 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3878 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3879 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
3880 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
3881 environment variable.
3882
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02003883 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
3884 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
3885 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
3886
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003887 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
3888 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
3889 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
3890 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003891
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003892 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
3893 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
3894 be automatically started (by internally calling
3895 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003896
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003897 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
3898 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
3899 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
3900 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
3901 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003902
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003903 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
3904 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00003905 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
3906 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
3907 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
3908 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
3909 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
3910 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
3911 access it during the boot procedure.
3912
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003913 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
3914 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
3915 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
3916 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
3917 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
3918 must be accessible by the kernel.
3919
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00003920 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
3921 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
3922 defined.
3923
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00003924 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
3925 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
3926 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
3927 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
3928 it must be saved and board must be reset.
3929
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003930 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
3931 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
3932 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
3933 is usually what you want since it allows for
3934 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
3935 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003936 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003937 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
3938 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
3939 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
3940 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003941
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003942 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
3943 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
3944 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
3945 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
3946 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
3947 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003948
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003949 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003950
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003951 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
3952 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
3953 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
3954 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
3955 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
3956 boot time on your system, but requires that this
3957 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00003958
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003959 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003960
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003961 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
3962 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003963
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003964 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003965
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003966 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00003967
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003968 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003969
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003970 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003971
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003972 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003973
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003974 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003975
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003976 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
3977 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003978
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02003979 => setenv ethact FEC
3980 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
3981 => setenv ethact SCC
3982 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003983
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01003984 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
3985 available network interfaces.
3986 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
3987
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003988 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003989 either succeed or fail without retrying.
3990 When set to "once" the network operation will
3991 fail when all the available network interfaces
3992 are tried once without success.
3993 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
3994 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003995
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01003996 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01003997
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003998 silent_linux - If set then Linux will be told to boot silently, by
Simon Glass8d51aac2013-07-16 20:10:00 -07003999 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
4000 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
4001 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
4002 is silent.
4003
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02004004 tftpsrcp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02004005 UDP source port.
4006
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02004007 tftpdstp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004008 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
4009
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004010 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
4011 we use the TFTP server's default block size
4012
4013 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
4014 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
4015 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
4016 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
4017 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
4018 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
4019 with unreliable TFTP servers.
4020
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02004021 tftptimeoutcountmax - maximum count of TFTP timeouts (no
4022 unit, minimum value = 0). Defines how many timeouts
4023 can happen during a single file transfer before that
4024 transfer is aborted. The default is 10, and 0 means
4025 'no timeouts allowed'. Increasing this value may help
4026 downloads succeed with high packet loss rates, or with
4027 unreliable TFTP servers or client hardware.
4028
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004029 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004030 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004031 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004032
Alexandre Messier50768f52016-02-01 17:08:57 -05004033 bootpretryperiod - Period during which BOOTP/DHCP sends retries.
4034 Unsigned value, in milliseconds. If not set, the period will
4035 be either the default (28000), or a value based on
4036 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT, if defined. This value has
4037 precedence over the valu based on CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT.
4038
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004039The following image location variables contain the location of images
4040used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
4041not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
4042variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4043server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4044loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4045flash or offset in NAND flash.
4046
4047*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
Fabio Estevamaed9fed2015-04-25 18:53:10 -03004048boards currently use other variables for these purposes, and some
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004049boards use these variables for other purposes.
4050
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004051Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4052----- --------- ----------- --------------
4053u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4054Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4055device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4056ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004058The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4059updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4060depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004061
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004062 bootfile - see above
4063 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4064 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4065 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4066 hostname - Target hostname
4067 ipaddr - see above
4068 netmask - Subnet Mask
4069 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4070 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004071
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004072
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004073There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004074
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004075 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4076 as type string and/or serial number
4077 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004078
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004079These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4080the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4081once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004082
4083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004084Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004085
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004086 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4087 with the "version" command. This variable is
4088 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004089
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004090
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004091Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4092only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004093
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004094
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004095Callback functions for environment variables:
4096---------------------------------------------
4097
4098For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004099when their values are changed. This functionality allows functions to
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004100be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
4101deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
4102effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
4103
4104The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
4105U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
4106
4107These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
4108static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
4109in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
4110associations. The list must be in the following format:
4111
4112 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
4113 list = entry[,list]
4114
4115If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
4116Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
4117
4118Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
4119with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
4120override any association in the static list. You can define
4121CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004122".callbacks" environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004123
Joe Hershbergerbdf1fe42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05004124If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
4125regular expression. This allows multiple variables to be connected to
4126the same callback without explicitly listing them all out.
4127
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004128
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004129Command Line Parsing:
4130=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004131
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004132There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4133the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004134
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004135Old, simple command line parser:
4136--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004137
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004138- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4139- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004140- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004141- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4142 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004143 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004144- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4145 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004146
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004147Hush shell:
4148-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004149
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004150- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4151 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4152 until...do...done, ...
4153- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4154 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4155 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4156 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004157
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004158General rules:
4159--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004160
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004161(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4162 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4163 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4164 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004165
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004166(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004167 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004168 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4169 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004170
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004171Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4172=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004173
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004174Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004175such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4176"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004177
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004178Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4179MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4180"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004181
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004182If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4183in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4184ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4185variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004186
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004187o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4188 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004189
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004190o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4191 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4192 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004193
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004194o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4195 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004196
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004197o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4198 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4199 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004200
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004201o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
Joe Hershbergerbef10142015-05-04 14:55:13 -05004202 is raised. If CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR is defined, then in this case
4203 a random, locally-assigned MAC is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004204
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004205If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004206will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004207may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4208The naming convention is as follows:
4209"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004210
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004211Image Formats:
4212==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004213
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004214U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4215images in two formats:
4216
4217New uImage format (FIT)
4218-----------------------
4219
4220Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4221to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4222components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4223SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4224
4225
4226Old uImage format
4227-----------------
4228
4229Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4230preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4231details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004232
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004233* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4234 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004235 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4236 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4237 INTEGRITY).
Andy Shevchenkodaab59a2017-07-05 16:25:22 +03004238* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004239 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
Andy Shevchenkodaab59a2017-07-05 16:25:22 +03004240 Currently supported: ARM, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004241* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4242* Load Address
4243* Entry Point
4244* Image Name
4245* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004246
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004247The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4248and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4249CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004250
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004251
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004252Linux Support:
4253==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004254
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004255Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4256easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4257U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004258
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004259U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4260special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4261"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4262instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4263serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004264
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004265- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4266 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4267 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004268
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004269- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4270 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004271
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004272- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4273 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4274 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4275 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4276 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4277 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004278
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004280Linux HOWTO:
4281============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004282
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004283Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4284---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004285
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004286U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4287configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4288(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4289Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004290
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004291But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004292
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004293Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4294include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004295Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4296and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004297as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004298
Simon Glass2eb31b12014-06-11 23:29:46 -06004299Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
4300If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
4301is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
4302doc/driver-model.
4303
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004304
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004305Configuring the Linux kernel:
4306-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004307
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004308No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4309device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004310
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004311
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004312Building a Linux Image:
4313-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004314
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004315With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4316not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4317"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4318U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4319which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4320100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004322Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004323
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004324 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004325 make oldconfig
4326 make dep
4327 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004328
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004329The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4330encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4331CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004332
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004333* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004334
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004335* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004336
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004337 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4338 -R .note -R .comment \
4339 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004340
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004341* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004342
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004343 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004344
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004345* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004346
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004347 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4348 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4349 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004350
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004351
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004352The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4353with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4354combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4355byte header containing information about target architecture,
4356operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4357stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004358
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004359"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4360print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004361
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004362In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4363contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4364checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004365
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004366 tools/mkimage -l image
4367 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004368
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004369The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4370from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004371
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004372 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4373 -n name -d data_file image
4374 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4375 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4376 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4377 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4378 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4379 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4380 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4381 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004382
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004383Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4384address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4385kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004386
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004387- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4388- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004389
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004390So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004391
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004392 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4393 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004394 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004395 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4396 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4397 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4398 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4399 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4400 Load Address: 0x00000000
4401 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004402
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004403To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004404
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004405 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4406 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4407 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4408 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4409 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4410 Load Address: 0x00000000
4411 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004412
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004413NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4414speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4415needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4416need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004417
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004418 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004419 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4420 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004421 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004422 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4423 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4424 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4425 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4426 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4427 Load Address: 0x00000000
4428 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004429
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004430
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004431Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4432when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004433
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004434 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4435 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4436 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4437 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4438 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4439 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4440 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4441 Load Address: 0x00000000
4442 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004443
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07004444The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
4445option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
4446option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
4447from the image:
4448
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraf41f5b72015-01-15 02:54:40 -02004449 tools/dumpimage -i image -T type -p position data_file
4450 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file'
4451 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4452 -p ==> 'position' (starting at 0) of the 'data_file' inside the 'image'
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07004453
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004454
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004455Installing a Linux Image:
4456-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004457
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004458To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4459you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004460
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004461 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004462
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004463The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4464image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4465address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4466specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4467command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004468
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004469Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4470TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004471
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004472 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004473
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004474 .......... done
4475 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004476
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004477 => loads 40100000
4478 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4479 ~>examples/image.srec
4480 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4481 ...
4482 15989 15990 15991 15992
4483 [file transfer complete]
4484 [connected]
4485 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004486
4487
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004488You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004489this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004490corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004491
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004492 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004493
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004494 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4495 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4496 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4497 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4498 Load Address: 00000000
4499 Entry Point: 0000000c
4500 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004501
4502
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004503Boot Linux:
4504-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004505
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004506The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4507memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4508of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4509parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4510"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004511
4512
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004513 => printenv bootargs
4514 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004515
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004516 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004517
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004518 => printenv bootargs
4519 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004520
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004521 => bootm 40020000
4522 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4523 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4524 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4525 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4526 Load Address: 00000000
4527 Entry Point: 0000000c
4528 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4529 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4530 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4531 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4532 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4533 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4534 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4535 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004536
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004537If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004538the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4539format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004540
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004541 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004542
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004543 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4544 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4545 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4546 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4547 Load Address: 00000000
4548 Entry Point: 0000000c
4549 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004550
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004551 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4552 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4553 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4554 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4555 Load Address: 00000000
4556 Entry Point: 00000000
4557 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004558
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004559 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4560 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4561 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4562 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4563 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4564 Load Address: 00000000
4565 Entry Point: 0000000c
4566 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4567 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4568 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4569 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4570 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4571 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4572 Load Address: 00000000
4573 Entry Point: 00000000
4574 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4575 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4576 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4577 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4578 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4579 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4580 ...
4581 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4582 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004583
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004584 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004585
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004586Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4587-----------
4588
4589First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4590titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4591following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4592flat device tree:
4593
4594=> print oftaddr
4595oftaddr=0x300000
4596=> print oft
4597oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4598=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4599Speed: 1000, full duplex
4600Using TSEC0 device
4601TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4602Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4603Load address: 0x300000
4604Loading: #
4605done
4606Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4607=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4608Speed: 1000, full duplex
4609Using TSEC0 device
4610TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4611Filename 'uImage'.
4612Load address: 0x200000
4613Loading:############
4614done
4615Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4616=> print loadaddr
4617loadaddr=200000
4618=> print oftaddr
4619oftaddr=0x300000
4620=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4621## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004622 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4623 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4624 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004625 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004626 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004627 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4628 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4629Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4630Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4631Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4632[snip]
4633
4634
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004635More About U-Boot Image Types:
4636------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004637
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004638U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004639
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004640 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4641 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4642 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4643 the Standalone Program.
4644 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4645 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4646 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4647 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4648 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4649 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4650 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4651 being started.
4652 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4653 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4654 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4655 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4656 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4657 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004658
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004659 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4660 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4661 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4662 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4663 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4664 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004665
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004666 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4667 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4668 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004669
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004670 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4671 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4672 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4673 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004674
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004675Booting the Linux zImage:
4676-------------------------
4677
4678On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4679using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4680as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4681
Tom Rini8ac28562013-05-16 11:40:11 -04004682Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004683kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4684address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4685format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4686
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004687
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004688Standalone HOWTO:
4689=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004690
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004691One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4692run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4693U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004694
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004695Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004696
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004697"Hello World" Demo:
4698-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004699
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004700'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4701application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4702It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4703like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004704
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004705 => loads
4706 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4707 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4708 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4709 [file transfer complete]
4710 [connected]
4711 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004712
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004713 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4714 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4715 Hello World
4716 argc = 7
4717 argv[0] = "40004"
4718 argv[1] = "Hello"
4719 argv[2] = "World!"
4720 argv[3] = "This"
4721 argv[4] = "is"
4722 argv[5] = "a"
4723 argv[6] = "test."
4724 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4725 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004726
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004727 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004728
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004729Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4730handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4731Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4732The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4733character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4734controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004735
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004736 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
4737 b - enable interrupts and start timer
4738 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
4739 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004740
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004741 => loads
4742 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4743 ~>examples/timer.srec
4744 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4745 [file transfer complete]
4746 [connected]
4747 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004748
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004749 => go 40004
4750 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4751 TIMERS=0xfff00980
4752 Using timer 1
4753 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004754
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004755Hit 'b':
4756 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
4757 Enabling timer
4758Hit '?':
4759 [q, b, e, ?] ........
4760 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
4761Hit '?':
4762 [q, b, e, ?] .
4763 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
4764Hit '?':
4765 [q, b, e, ?] .
4766 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
4767Hit '?':
4768 [q, b, e, ?] .
4769 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
4770Hit 'e':
4771 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
4772Hit 'q':
4773 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004774
4775
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004776Minicom warning:
4777================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004778
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004779Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
4780"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
4781consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
4782Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
4783especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00004784use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
4785http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
4786for help with kermit.
4787
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004788
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004789Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
4790configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004791
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004792 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
4793 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
4794 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004795
4796
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004797NetBSD Notes:
4798=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004799
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004800Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
4801(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004802
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004803Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
4804NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
4805need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
4806Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
4807attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
4808missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004809
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004810 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
4811 # mkdir powerpc
4812 # ln -s powerpc machine
4813 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
4814 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004815
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004816Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
4817and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004818
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004819Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
4820stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
4821proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
4822tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00004823meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004824
4825
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004826Implementation Internals:
4827=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004828
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004829The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
4830implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
4831inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
4832hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004833
4834
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004835Initial Stack, Global Data:
4836---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004837
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004838The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
4839starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
4840system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
4841This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
4842is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
4843at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
4844options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
4845models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
4846MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
4847locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004848
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004849 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004850 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004851
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004852 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
4853 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
4854 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
4855 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004856
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004857 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
4858 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
4859 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
4860 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
4861 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004862 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004863 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
4864 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004865
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004866 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
4867 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004868 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004869 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
4870 board designers haven't used it for something that would
4871 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
4872 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004873
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004874 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004875 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
4876 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02004877 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004878 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
4879 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
4880 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
4881 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
4882 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004883
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004884 -Chris Hallinan
4885 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004886
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004887It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
4888code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004889
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004890* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
4891 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004892
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004893* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitly initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004894 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
4895 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004896
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004897* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
4898 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004899
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004900Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004901normal global data to share information between the code. But it
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004902turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
4903simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
4904functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
4905functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
4906the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
4907place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
4908reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004909
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004910When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
4911relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
4912GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004913
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004914For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
4915 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004916 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004917 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
4918 R5-R10: parameter passing
4919 R13: small data area pointer
4920 R30: GOT pointer
4921 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004922
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01004923 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
4924 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
4925 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004926
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004927 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004928
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004929 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
4930 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
4931 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
4932 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
4933 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
4934 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004935
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004936On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004937
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004938 R0: function argument word/integer result
4939 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02004940 R9: platform specific
4941 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004942 R11: argument (frame) pointer
4943 R12: temporary workspace
4944 R13: stack pointer
4945 R14: link register
4946 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004947
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02004948 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
4949
4950 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004951
Thomas Chou0df01fd32010-05-21 11:08:03 +08004952On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
4953 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
4954
4955 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4956
4957 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
4958 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
4959
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004960On NDS32, the following registers are used:
4961
4962 R0-R1: argument/return
4963 R2-R5: argument
4964 R15: temporary register for assembler
4965 R16: trampoline register
4966 R28: frame pointer (FP)
4967 R29: global pointer (GP)
4968 R30: link register (LP)
4969 R31: stack pointer (SP)
4970 PC: program counter (PC)
4971
4972 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
4973
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02004974NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
4975or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004976
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004977Memory Management:
4978------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004979
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004980U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
4981MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004982
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004983The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
4984controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
4985memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
4986physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004987
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004988U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
4989TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
4990booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
4991to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004992memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004993configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
4994Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004995
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004996Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
4997of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004998
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004999So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
5000this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005001
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005002 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
5003 :
5004 0x0000 1FFF
5005 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
5006 :
5007 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005008
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005009 :
5010 :
5011 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
5012 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
5013 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
5014 :
5015 0x00FD FFFF
5016 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
5017 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
5018 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
5019 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005020
5021
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005022System Initialization:
5023----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005024
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005025In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005026(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005027configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the on board Flash memory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005028To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
5029To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
5030initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
Heiko Schocher2eb48ff2017-06-07 17:33:10 +02005031which provide such a feature like), or in a locked part of the data
5032cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core, the caches and
5033the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005034
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005035Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
5036preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
5037(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
5038on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
5039programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
5040simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
5041banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005042
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005043When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
5044different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
5045bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
50460x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
5047contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005048
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005049Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
5050and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
5051Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
5052pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005053
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005054Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
5055until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
5056running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
5057new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005058
5059
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005060U-Boot Porting Guide:
5061----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005062
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005063[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
5064list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005065
5066
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005067int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005068{
5069 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005070
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005071 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
5072 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005073
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005074 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005075 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005076 return 0;
5077 }
5078
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005079 Download latest U-Boot source;
5080
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005081 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005082
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005083 if (clueless)
5084 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005085
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005086 while (learning) {
5087 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005088 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
5089 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005090 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005091 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005092 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005093
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005094 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5095 Buy a BDI3000;
5096 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005097 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005098
5099 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5100 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5101 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5102 } else {
5103 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5104 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005105 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005106 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5107 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005108
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005109 while (!accepted) {
5110 while (!running) {
5111 do {
5112 Add / modify source code;
5113 } until (compiles);
5114 Debug;
5115 if (clueless)
5116 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5117 }
5118 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5119 if (reasonable critiques)
5120 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5121 else
5122 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005123 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005124
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005125 return 0;
5126}
5127
5128void no_more_time (int sig)
5129{
5130 hire_a_guru();
5131}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005132
5133
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005134Coding Standards:
5135-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005136
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005137All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Baruch Siach659208d2017-12-10 17:34:35 +02005138coding style; see the kernel coding style guide at
5139https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/process/coding-style.html, and the
5140script "scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005141
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005142Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5143MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005144reformatted to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005145sources.
5146
5147Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5148Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5149in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005150
5151Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5152- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005153- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005154- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005155- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005156- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5157
5158Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5159with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005160
5161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005162Submitting Patches:
5163-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005164
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005165Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5166establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5167may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005168
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005169Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005170
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005171Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
S. Lockwood-Childs1dade182017-11-14 22:56:42 -08005172see https://lists.denx.de/listinfo/u-boot
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005173
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005174When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5175it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005176
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005177* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5178 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5179 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005180
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005181* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5182 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005183
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005184* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5185
Robert P. J. Day7207b362015-12-19 07:16:10 -05005186* For major contributions, add a MAINTAINERS file with your
5187 information and associated file and directory references.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005188
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +02005189* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
5190 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005191
5192* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5193 document these in the README file.
5194
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005195* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5196 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005197 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005198 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5199 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005200
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005201 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5202 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5203 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005204
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005205 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5206 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5207 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5208 affected files).
5209
5210 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5211 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005212
5213* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5214 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5215
5216* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5217 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5218
5219
5220Notes:
5221
Simon Glass6de80f22016-07-27 20:33:08 -06005222* Before sending the patch, run the buildman script on your patched
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005223 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5224 for any of the boards.
5225
5226* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5227 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5228 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5229
5230* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5231 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5232 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5233 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5234 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5235 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005236
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005237* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5238 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5239 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5240 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.